agora inbox for [email protected]help / color / mirror / Atom feed
[PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning 50+ messages / 2 participants [nested] [flat]
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1473 ++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------- 1 file changed, 722 insertions(+), 751 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index d1e915c11a..2cd75a9673 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,123 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> offers built-in support for the + following forms of partitioning: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + + If your application needs to use other forms of partitioning not listed + above, alternative methods such as inheritance and + <literal>UNION ALL</literal> views can be used instead. Such methods + offer flexibility but do not have some of the performance benefits + of built-in declarative partitioning. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,74 +2899,72 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> - Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. Partitions may have their own + indexes, constraints and default values, distinct from other partitions. + They do not inherit indexes from the partitioned table. See + <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details on creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> - Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see - <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the - <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. + It is not possible to turn a regular table into a partitioned table or + vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table + containing data as a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a + partition from a partitioned table turning it into a standalone table; + see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the + <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> + sub-commands. </para> <para> Individual partitions are linked to the partitioned table with inheritance - behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the inheritance - features discussed in the previous section with partitioned tables and - partitions. For example, partitions cannot have any other parents than - the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular table inherit - from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. That means - partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with - regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the - partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + behind-the-scenes, however it is not possible to use some of the + inheritance features discussed in the previous section with partitioned + tables and partitions. For example, a partition cannot have any parents + other than the partitioned table it is a partition of, nor can a regular + table inherit from a partitioned table making the latter its parent. + That means partitioned table and partitions do not participate in + inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting + of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance + hierarchy, all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> Both <literal>CHECK</literal> and <literal>NOT NULL</literal> constraints of a partitioned table are always inherited by all its - partitions. There cannot be any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - that are marked <literal>NO INHERIT</literal>. + partitions. <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints that are marked + <literal>NO INHERIT</literal> are not allowed. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables - would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + will cause an error for partitioned tables in the case of + schema-modifying commands such as most <literal>ALTER TABLE</literal> + commands. For example, dropping a column from only the parent does + not make sense for partitioned tables. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. - It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions - with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It + is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with + <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to + partitions after-the-fact using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be + added as a partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> + only if their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,487 +2978,505 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), - although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), + although certain limitations exist in their usage. For example, data + inserted into the partitioned table is not routed to foreign table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> in this + case) and the list of column(s) to use as the partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + You may decide to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning if it's known that each of the selected columns will + divide the incoming data using successively more granular partition + criteria. Whereas using fewer columns may lead to coarser-grained + partitioning causing each partition to accept bigger set of data than + might be desirable. A query accessing the partitioned table will have + to scan fewer partitions if the conditions involve some or all of these + columns. For example, consider a table range partitioned using columns + <structfield>lastname</> and <structfield>firstname</> (in that order) + as the partition key. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into the parent table that does not map + to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; appropriate + partition must be added manually. </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. - </para> - - </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> - - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> - - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible to specify + tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> - <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> + </para> - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> (or data that is directly inserted + into <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, provided it satisfies its + partition constraint) will be further redirected to one of its + partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. Partition + key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, although + care must be taken when specifying the bounds of a sub-partition + such that the set of data it accepts constitutes a subset of what + the partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check + if that's really the case. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + Create an index on the key column(s), as well as any other indexes you + might want for every partition. - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> <listitem> <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: - - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> - - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - </sect2> + </sect3> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the - partitions will inherit. - </para> - <para> - This table will contain no data. Do not define any check - constraints on this table, unless you intend them to - be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point - in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. - </para> - </listitem> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from - the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns - to the set inherited from the master. - </para> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> - <para> - We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they - are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables - (or, possibly, foreign tables). - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <listitem> - <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. - </para> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> + + <para> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <para> - Typical examples would be: <programlisting> -CHECK ( x = 1 ) -CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) -CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; </programlisting> - Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap - between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common - mistake is to set up range constraints like: + + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + <programlisting> -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) -CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work + +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); </programlisting> - This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value - 200 belongs in. - </para> + </para> - <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may then drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </sect3> - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + The following limitations apply to partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. This also means that there is no way to create a primary + key, unique constraint, or exclusion constraint spanning all + partitions; it is only possible to constrain each leaf partition + individually. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, foreign + keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor are foreign + key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables + will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the + alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be + created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing + uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning + hierarchy. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. + </para> + </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, + not the partitioned table as it is not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + While the built-in declarative partitioning is suitable for most + common use cases, there are some circumstances where a more flexible + approach may be useful. Partitioning can be implemented using table + inheritance, which allows for several features which are not supported + by declarative partitioning, such as: + + <itemizedlist> <listitem> <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. + Partitioning enforces a rule that all partitions must have exactly + the same set of columns as the parent, but table inheritance allows + children to have extra columns not present in the parent. </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. + Table inheritance allows for multiple inheritance. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. + Declarative partitioning only supports list and range partitioning, + whereas table inheritance allows data to be divided in a manner of + the user's choosing. (Note, however, that if constraint exclusion is + unable to prune partitions effectively, query performance will be very + poor.) </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. + Some operations require a stronger lock when using declarative + partitioning than when using table inheritance. For example, adding + or removing a partition to or from a partitioned table requires taking + an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table, + whereas a <literal>SHARE UPDATE EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock is enough + in the case of regular inheritance. </para> </listitem> - - </orderedlist> + </itemizedlist> </para> - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> + <para> + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, use + the following steps: - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> + <listitem> + <para> + Create the <quote>master</quote> table, from which all of the + partitions will inherit. This table will contain no data. Do not + define any check constraints on this table, unless you intend them + to be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in + defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. For our + example, master table is the <structname>measurement</structname> + table as originally defined. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + Create several <quote>child</quote> tables that each inherit from + the master table. Normally, these tables will not add any columns + to the set inherited from the master. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: + <para> + We will refer to the child tables as partitions, though they are + in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, + foreign tables). + </para> + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); ... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. + </para> - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + Typical examples would be: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( x = 1 ) +CHECK ( county IN ( 'Oxfordshire', 'Buckinghamshire', 'Warwickshire' )) +CHECK ( outletID >= 100 AND outletID < 200 ) +</programlisting> + Ensure that the constraints guarantee that there is no overlap + between the key values permitted in different partitions. A common + mistake is to set up range constraints like: +<programlisting> +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 100 AND 200 ) +CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) +</programlisting> + This is wrong since it is not clear which partition the key value + 200 belongs in. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + <para> + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> + </para> + </listitem> - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO - measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the - appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching - a suitable trigger function to the master table. - If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can - use a very simple trigger function: + <listitem> + <para> + We want our application to be able to say <literal>INSERT INTO + measurement ...</> and have the data be redirected into the + appropriate partition table. We can arrange that by attaching + a suitable trigger function to the master table. + If data will be added only to the latest partition, we can + use a very simple trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3363,9 +3488,11 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> - After creating the function, we create a trigger which - calls the trigger function: + <para> + After creating the function, we create a trigger which + calls the trigger function: <programlisting> CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger @@ -3373,15 +3500,15 @@ CREATE TRIGGER insert_measurement_trigger FOR EACH ROW EXECUTE PROCEDURE measurement_insert_trigger(); </programlisting> - We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always - points to the current partition. The trigger definition does - not need to be updated, however. - </para> + We must redefine the trigger function each month so that it always + points to the current partition. The trigger definition does + not need to be updated, however. + </para> - <para> - We might want to insert data and have the server automatically - locate the partition into which the row should be added. We - could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: + <para> + We might want to insert data and have the server automatically + locate the partition into which the row should be added. We + could do this with a more complex trigger function, for example: <programlisting> CREATE OR REPLACE FUNCTION measurement_insert_trigger() @@ -3393,183 +3520,120 @@ BEGIN ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND NEW.logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) THEN INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m03 VALUES (NEW.*); - ... - ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND - NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); - ELSE - RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; - END IF; - RETURN NULL; -END; -$$ -LANGUAGE plpgsql; -</programlisting> - - The trigger definition is the same as before. - Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. - </para> - - <para> - While this function is more complex than the single-month case, - it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be - added in advance of being needed. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, - if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have - shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts - of this example. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); + ... + ELSIF ( NEW.logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND + NEW.logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) THEN + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); + ELSE + RAISE EXCEPTION 'Date out of range. Fix the measurement_insert_trigger() function!'; + END IF; + RETURN NULL; +END; +$$ +LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + The trigger definition is the same as before. + Note that each <literal>IF</literal> test must exactly match the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraint for its partition. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> - </para> - </listitem> + <para> + While this function is more complex than the single-month case, + it doesn't need to be updated as often, since branches can be + added in advance of being needed. + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. - </para> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> + <note> + <para> + In practice it might be best to check the newest partition first, + if most inserts go into that partition. For simplicity we have + shown the trigger's tests in the same order as in other parts + of this example. + </para> + </note> - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: + <para> + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> - </para> - - <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the + overhead is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this + method might be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most + cases, however, the trigger method will offer better performance. + </para> - </sect2> + <para> + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> + </para> - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + <para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> - - <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> + </para> - When using a partitioned table: + <para> + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. - </para> - - <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + <para> + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition + just as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,17 +3641,9 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may want to create the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after the data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 @@ -3598,31 +3654,64 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 -- possibly some other data preparation work ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> - <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. - </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3721,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,160 +3805,15 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Using the <literal>ON CONFLICT</literal> clause with partitioned tables - will cause an error if <literal>DO UPDATE</literal> is specified as the - alternative action, because unique or exclusion constraints can only be - created on individual partitions. There is no support for enforcing - uniqueness (or an exclusion constraint) across an entire partitioning - hierarchy. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> + Constraint exclusion is also used for declarative partitioning, however + it is not required to create <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints for + individual partitions as when using table inheritance. </para> <para> - The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently - used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: + The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is used by + both inheritance and partitioned tables: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -3909,6 +3854,32 @@ ANALYZE measurement; </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67 Content-Type: text/plain Content-Disposition: inline Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit MIME-Version: 1.0 -- Sent via pgsql-hackers mailing list ([email protected]) To make changes to your subscription: http://www.postgresql.org/mailpref/pgsql-hackers --------------4AB4E704D39F2BF05E79CD67-- ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------434C61868FD2E7C005F82712 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning @ 2017-03-03 07:39 amit <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: amit @ 2017-03-03 07:39 UTC (permalink / raw) Merge sections Partitioned Tables and Partitioning into one section called Table Partitioning and Related Solutions. --- doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml | 1359 +++++++++++++++++++++++++------------------------ 1 file changed, 707 insertions(+), 652 deletions(-) diff --git a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml index 09b5b3ff70..a2dd39df54 100644 --- a/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml +++ b/doc/src/sgml/ddl.sgml @@ -2772,14 +2772,181 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </sect2> </sect1> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - <title>Partitioned Tables</title> + <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> + <title>Table Partitioning and Related Solutions</title> + + <indexterm> + <primary>partitioning</primary> + </indexterm> + + <indexterm> + <primary>table</primary> + <secondary>partitioning</secondary> + </indexterm> <indexterm> <primary>partitioned table</primary> </indexterm> <para> + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table + partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement + partitioning as part of your database design. + </para> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> + <title>Overview</title> + + <para> + Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table into + smaller physical pieces. Partitioning can provide several benefits: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, + particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a + single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning + substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and + making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes + fit in memory. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single + partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage + of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an + index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing + partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. + Doing <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> followed by + <command>DROP TABLE</> is far faster than a bulk operation. These + commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> overhead + caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. + </para> + </listitem> + + <listitem> + <para> + Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + + The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would + otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will + benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a + rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical + memory of the database server. + </para> + + <para> + The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in + <productname>PostgreSQL</productname>: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Range Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined + by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between + the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For + example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of + identifiers for particular business objects. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>List Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values + appear in each partition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + The following partitioning methods are currently supported: + + <variablelist> + <varlistentry> + <term>Declarative Partitioning</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One creates a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm> by specifying + the partitioning method and a set of columns as the partition key. + <firstterm>Partitions</firstterm>, which contain actual data inserted + into the table, are created by specifying what subset of the data it + accepts. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using inheritance</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent + table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to + represent the entire data set. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Using UNION ALL views</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + One can define a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> view over + <literal>SELECT</literal> on individual tables, each of which + contains a partition of data. Partitions are added or removed + by updating the view definition. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + + <varlistentry> + <term>Accessing Tables using BRIN Indexes</term> + + <listitem> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index is, + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. Scanning + a large table using a <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index results in + reading only a portion of the table, which is often why partitioning + is implemented. + </para> + </listitem> + </varlistentry> + </variablelist> + </para> + + <para> + Each of the above mentioned methods is described below. + </para> + </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative"> + <title>Declarative Partitioning</title> + + <para> PostgreSQL offers a way to specify how to divide a table into pieces called partitions. The table that is divided is referred to as a <firstterm>partitioned table</firstterm>. The specification consists @@ -2790,25 +2957,29 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> All rows inserted into a partitioned table will be routed to one of the <firstterm>partitions</firstterm> based on the value of the partition - key. Each partition has a subset defined by its <firstterm>partition - bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported partitioning methods include - range and list, wherein each partition is assigned a range of keys or - a list of keys, respectively. + key. Each partition has a subset of the data defined by its + <firstterm>partition bounds</firstterm>. Currently supported + partitioning methods include range and list, where each partition is + assigned a range of keys and a list of keys, respectively. </para> <para> Partitions may have their own indexes, constraints and default values, - distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not inherit indexes from - the partitioned table. + distinct from other partitions. Partitions do not currently inherit + indexes from the partitioned table. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> for more details creating partitioned + tables and partitions. </para> <para> Partitions may themselves be defined as partitioned tables, referred to as - <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. See <xref linkend="sql-createtable"> - for more details creating partitioned tables and partitions. It is not - currently possible to alter a regular table into a partitioned table or - vice versa. However, it is possible to add a regular table containing - data into a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see + <firstterm>sub-partitioning</firstterm>. It is not currently possible to + alter a regular table into a partitioned table or vice versa. However, + it is possible to add a regular or partitioned table containing data into + a partition of a partitioned table, or remove a partition; see <xref linkend="sql-altertable"> to learn more about the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> and <command>DETACH PARTITION</> sub-commands. </para> @@ -2823,8 +2994,8 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); partitioned table and partitions do not participate in inheritance with regular tables. Since a partition hierarchy consisting of the partitioned table and its partitions is still an inheritance hierarchy, - all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in the previous - section (<xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) with some exceptions, most notably: + all the normal rules of inheritance apply as described in + <xref linkend="ddl-inherit"> with some exceptions, most notably: <itemizedlist> <listitem> @@ -2840,13 +3011,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); <para> The <literal>ONLY</literal> notation used to exclude child tables would either cause error or will be ignored in some cases for - partitioned tables. For example, specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> - when querying data from a partitioned table would not make much sense, - because all the data is contained in partitions, so this raises an - error. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying schema is - not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables where it may be - fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, dropping a column - from only the parent); an error will be thrown in that case. + partitioned tables. Specifying <literal>ONLY</literal> when modifying + schema is not desirable in certain cases with partitioned tables + whereas it may be fine for regular inheritance parents (for example, + dropping a column from only the parent); an error will be thrown in + that case. </para> </listitem> @@ -2855,9 +3024,9 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); Partitions cannot have columns that are not present in the parent. It is neither possible to specify columns when creating partitions with <command>CREATE TABLE</> nor is it possible to add columns to - partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added with - <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> if their columns exactly - match the parent, including oids. + partitions using <command>ALTER TABLE</>. Tables may be added as a + partition with <command>ALTER TABLE ... ATTACH PARTITION</> only if + their columns exactly match the parent, including oids. </para> </listitem> @@ -2871,199 +3040,353 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); </para> <para> - Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="ddl-foreign-data">), + Partitions can also be foreign tables (see <xref linkend="sql-createforeigntable">), although certain limitations exist currently in their usage. For example, - data inserted into the partitioned table cannot be routed to foreign table - partitions. + data inserted into the partitioned table is currently not routed to foreign + table partitions. </para> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-example"> + <title>Example</title> + <para> - There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: - <itemizedlist> + Suppose we are constructing a database for a large ice cream company. + The company measures peak temperatures every day as well as ice cream + sales in each region. Conceptually, we want a table like: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +); +</programlisting> + + We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or + quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare + online reports for management. To reduce the amount of old data that + needs to be stored, we decide to only keep the most recent 3 years + worth of data. At the beginning of each month we will remove the oldest + month's data. In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet + all of our different requirements for the measurements table. + </para> + + <para> + To use declarative partitioning in this case, use the following steps: + + <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> - It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions - automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate - commands. + Create <structname>measurement</structname> table as a partitioned + table by specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which + includes the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or + <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the + partition key. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement ( + city_id int not null, + logdate date not null, + peaktemp int, + unitsales int +) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> + <note> + <para> + To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range + partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned + in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, + especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. + If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions + if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on + leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of + partitions of interest. The first partition key column with + inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of + those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. + </para> + </note> + <para> - It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables - that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. - Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized - using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + To be able to insert data into this table, one must create partitions, + as described below. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, - foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor - are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + Create partitions. Each partition's definition must specify the bounds + that correspond to the partitioning method and partition key of the + parent. Note that specifying bounds such that the new partition's + values will overlap with those in one or more existing partitions will + cause an error. Inserting data into into the parent table that does + not map to one of the existing partitions will cause an error; + appropriate partition must be added manually. + </para> + + <para> + Partitions thus created are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> + tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). It is possible, for example, to + specify tablespace, storage parameters for each partition separately. + </para> + + <para> + It is not necessary to create table constraints describing partition + boundary condition for partitions. Instead, partition constraints are + generated implicitly from the partition bound specification whenever + there is need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into the + parent table is automatically inserted into the appropriate partition, + it is not necessary to create triggers for the same. + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01') + +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01') + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; + +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace + WITH (parallel_workers = 4); +</programlisting> </para> + + <note> + <para> + To implement sub-partitioning, specify the + <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create + individual partitions, for example: + +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') + PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); +</programlisting> + + After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, + any data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to + <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one + of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. + Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, + although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of + sub-partitions such that the accepted set of data constitutes a + subset of what a partition's own bounds allows; the system does not + try to check if that's really the case. + </para> + </note> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not - the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + Create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. + Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition + from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is + not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first + place. This might change in future releases. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); +... +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); +CREATE INDEX ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); +</programlisting> </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> + + <listitem> + <para> + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. + </para> + </listitem> + </orderedlist> </para> <para> - A detailed example that shows how to use partitioned tables is discussed in - the next chapter. + In the above example we would be creating a new partition each month, so + it might be wise to write a script that generates the required DDL + automatically. </para> - - </sect1> + </sect3> - <sect1 id="ddl-partitioning"> - <title>Partitioning</title> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> - <indexterm> - <primary>partitioning</primary> - </indexterm> + <para> + Normally the set of partitions established when initially defining the + the table are not intended to remain static. It is common to want to + remove old partitions of data and periodically add new partitions for + new data. One of the most important advantages of partitioning is + precisely that it allows this otherwise painful task to be executed + nearly instantaneously by manipulating the partition structure, rather + than physically moving large amounts of data around. + </para> - <indexterm> - <primary>table</primary> - <secondary>partitioning</secondary> - </indexterm> + <para> + The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition + that is no longer necessary: +<programlisting> +DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have + to individually delete every record. Note however that the above command + requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent + table. + </para> <para> - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports basic table - partitioning. This section describes why and how to implement - partitioning as part of your database design. - </para> + Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from + the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own + right: - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-overview"> - <title>Overview</title> +<programlisting> +ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +</programlisting> + + This allows further operations to be performed on the data before + it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up + the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or + similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data + into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run + reports. + </para> <para> - Partitioning refers to splitting what is logically one large table - into smaller physical pieces. - Partitioning can provide several benefits: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - Query performance can be improved dramatically in certain situations, - particularly when most of the heavily accessed rows of the table are in a - single partition or a small number of partitions. The partitioning - substitutes for leading columns of indexes, reducing index size and - making it more likely that the heavily-used parts of the indexes - fit in memory. - </para> - </listitem> + Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an + empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions + were created above: - <listitem> - <para> - When queries or updates access a large percentage of a single - partition, performance can be improved by taking advantage - of sequential scan of that partition instead of using an - index and random access reads scattered across the whole table. - </para> - </listitem> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01') + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; +</programlisting> - <listitem> - <para> - Bulk loads and deletes can be accomplished by adding or removing - partitions, if that requirement is planned into the partitioning design. - <command>ALTER TABLE NO INHERIT</> or <command>ALTER TABLE DETACH PARTITION</> - and <command>DROP TABLE</> are both far faster than a bulk operation. - These commands also entirely avoid the <command>VACUUM</command> - overhead caused by a bulk <command>DELETE</>. - </para> - </listitem> + As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the + new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper + partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and + transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: - <listitem> - <para> - Seldom-used data can be migrated to cheaper and slower storage media. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 + (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS) + TABLESPACE fasttablespace; - The benefits will normally be worthwhile only when a table would - otherwise be very large. The exact point at which a table will - benefit from partitioning depends on the application, although a - rule of thumb is that the size of the table should exceed the physical - memory of the database server. - </para> +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 + CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); - <para> - Currently, <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> supports partitioning - using two methods: +\copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' +-- possibly some other data preparation work - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Table Inheritance</term> +ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 + FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +</programlisting> + </para> - <listitem> - <para> - Each partition must be created as a child table of a single parent - table. The parent table itself is normally empty; it exists just to - represent the entire data set. You should be familiar with - inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">) before attempting to - set up partitioning with it. This was the only method to implement - partitioning in older versions. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <tip> + <para> + Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is + recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to + be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the + same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit + partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be + scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an + <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. + One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> + is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + </para> + </tip> + </sect3> - <varlistentry> - <term>Using Partitioned Tables</term> + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-declarative-limitations"> + <title>Limitations</title> - <listitem> - <para> - See last section for some general information: - <xref linkend="ddl-partitioned-tables"> - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <para> + There are currently the following limitations of using partitioned tables: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to add same set of indexes on all partitions + automatically. Indexes must be added to each partition with separate + commands. + </para> + </listitem> - <para> - The following forms of partitioning can be implemented in - <productname>PostgreSQL</productname> using either of the above mentioned - methods, although the latter provides dedicated syntax for each: + <listitem> + <para> + It is currently not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables + that include all rows from all partitions in one global index. + Consequently, it is not possible to create constraints that are realized + using an index such as <literal>UNIQUE</>. + </para> + </listitem> - <variablelist> - <varlistentry> - <term>Range Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + Since primary keys are not supported on partitioned tables, + foreign keys referencing partitioned tables are not supported, nor + are foreign key references from a partitioned table to some other table. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned into <quote>ranges</quote> defined - by a key column or set of columns, with no overlap between - the ranges of values assigned to different partitions. For - example one might partition by date ranges, or by ranges of - identifiers for particular business objects. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> + <listitem> + <para> + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. + </para> + </listitem> - <varlistentry> - <term>List Partitioning</term> + <listitem> + <para> + An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to + another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the + implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might + change in future releases. + </para> + </listitem> - <listitem> - <para> - The table is partitioned by explicitly listing which key values - appear in each partition. - </para> - </listitem> - </varlistentry> - </variablelist> - </para> + <listitem> + <para> + Row triggers, if necessary, must be defined on individual partitions, not + the partitioned table as it is currently not supported. + </para> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation"> - <title>Implementing Partitioning</title> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-implementation-inheritance"> + <title>Implementation Using Inheritance</title> + <para> + In some cases, one may want to add columns to partitions that are not + present in the parent table which is not possible to do with the above + method. For such cases, partitioning can be implemented using + inheritance (see <xref linkend="ddl-inherit">). + </para> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-example"> + <title>Example</title> <para> - To set up a partitioned table using inheritance, do the following: + We use the same <structname>measurement</structname> table we used + above. To implement it as a partitioned table using inheritance, do the + following: <orderedlist spacing="compact"> <listitem> <para> @@ -3076,6 +3399,11 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); be applied equally to all partitions. There is no point in defining any indexes or unique constraints on it, either. </para> + + <para> + In case of our example, master table is the original + <structname>measurement</structname> as originally defined. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> @@ -3090,12 +3418,27 @@ VALUES ('Albany', NULL, NULL, 'NY'); are in every way normal <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables). </para> + + <para> + This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each + month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP + TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new + child table for the new month's data. +<programlisting> +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 () INHERITS (measurement); +... +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 () INHERITS (measurement); +CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 () INHERITS (measurement); +</programlisting> + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Add table constraints to the partition tables to define the - allowed key values in each partition. + Add non-overlapping table constraints to the partition tables to + define the allowed key values in each partition. </para> <para> @@ -3117,230 +3460,53 @@ CHECK ( outletID BETWEEN 200 AND 300 ) </para> <para> - Note that there is no difference in - syntax between range and list partitioning; those terms are - descriptive only. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is - not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. - If you intend the key values to be unique then you should - always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each - partition.) - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Optionally, define a trigger or rule to redirect data inserted into - the master table to the appropriate partition. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> - configuration parameter is not disabled in - <filename>postgresql.conf</>. - If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - To use partitioned tables, do the following: - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - Create <quote>master</quote> table as a partitioned table by - specifying the <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause, which includes - the partitioning method (<literal>RANGE</literal> or - <literal>LIST</literal>) and the list of column(s) to use as the - partition key. To be able to insert data into the table, one must - create partitions, as described below. - </para> - - <note> - <para> - To decide when to use multiple columns in the partition key for range - partitioning, consider whether queries accessing the partitioned - in question will include conditions that involve multiple columns, - especially the columns being considered to be the partition key. - If so, the optimizer can create a plan that will scan fewer partitions - if a query's conditions are such that there is equality constraint on - leading partition key columns, because they limit the number of - partitions of interest. The first partition key column with - inequality constraint also further eliminates some partitions of - those chosen by equality constraints on earlier columns. - </para> - </note> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Create partitions of the master partitioned table, with the partition - bounds specified for each partition matching the partitioning method - and partition key of the master table. Note that specifying partition - bounds such that the new partition's values will overlap with one or - more existing partitions will cause an error. It is only after - creating partitions that one is able to insert data into the master - partitioned table, provided it maps to one of the existing partitions. - If a data row does not map to any of the existing partitions, it will - cause an error. - </para> - - <para> - Partitions thus created are also in every way normal - <productname>PostgreSQL</> tables (or, possibly, foreign tables), - whereas partitioned tables differ in a number of ways. - </para> - - <para> - It is not necessary to create table constraints for partitions. - Instead, partition constraints are generated implicitly whenever - there is a need to refer to them. Also, since any data inserted into - the master partitioned table is automatically inserted into the - appropriate partition, it is not necessary to create triggers for the - same. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Just like with inheritance, create an index on the key column(s), - as well as any other indexes you might want for every partition. - Note that it is currently not supported to propagate index definition - from the master partitioned table to its partitions; in fact, it is - not possible to define indexes on partitioned tables in the first - place. This might change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Currently, partitioned tables also depend on constraint exclusion - for query optimization, so ensure that the - <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> configuration parameter is - not disabled in <filename>postgresql.conf</>. This might change in - future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - For example, suppose we are constructing a database for a large - ice cream company. The company measures peak temperatures every - day as well as ice cream sales in each region. Conceptually, - we want a table like: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -); -</programlisting> - - We know that most queries will access just the last week's, month's or - quarter's data, since the main use of this table will be to prepare - online reports for management. - To reduce the amount of old data that needs to be stored, we - decide to only keep the most recent 3 years worth of data. At the - beginning of each month we will remove the oldest month's data. - </para> - - <para> - In this situation we can use partitioning to help us meet all of our - different requirements for the measurements table. Following the - steps outlined above for both methods, partitioning can be set up as - follows: - </para> - - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> - <para> - The master table is the <structname>measurement</> table, declared - exactly as above. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - Next we create one partition for each active month: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); -</programlisting> - - Each of the partitions are complete tables in their own right, - but they inherit their definitions from the - <structname>measurement</> table. - </para> - - <para> - This solves one of our problems: deleting old data. Each - month, all we will need to do is perform a <command>DROP - TABLE</command> on the oldest child table and create a new - child table for the new month's data. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - We must provide non-overlapping table constraints. Rather than - just creating the partition tables as above, the table creation - script should really be: + It would be better to instead create partitions as follows: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2006-03-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-04-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + ... CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-11-01' AND logdate < DATE '2007-12-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2007-12-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-01-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); + CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 ( CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> </para> + + <para> + Note that there is no difference in syntax between range and list + partitioning; those terms are descriptive only. + </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - We probably need indexes on the key columns too: - + For each partition, create an index on the key column(s), + as well as any other indexes you might want. (The key index is + not strictly necessary, but in most scenarios it is helpful. + If you intend the key values to be unique then you should + always create a unique or primary-key constraint for each + partition.) <programlisting> CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m02_logdate ON measurement_y2006m02 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2006m03_logdate ON measurement_y2006m03 (logdate); -... CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m11_logdate ON measurement_y2007m11 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2007m12_logdate ON measurement_y2007m12 (logdate); CREATE INDEX measurement_y2008m01_logdate ON measurement_y2008m01 (logdate); </programlisting> - - We choose not to add further indexes at this time. </para> </listitem> @@ -3363,7 +3529,9 @@ END; $$ LANGUAGE plpgsql; </programlisting> + </para> + <para> After creating the function, we create a trigger which calls the trigger function: @@ -3425,151 +3593,88 @@ LANGUAGE plpgsql; of this example. </para> </note> - </listitem> - </orderedlist> - </para> - - <para> - Steps when using a partitioned table are as follows: - </para> - <para> - <orderedlist spacing="compact"> - <listitem> <para> - Create the <structname>measurement</> table as a partitioned table: + A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate + partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the + master table. For example: <programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement ( - city_id int not null, - logdate date not null, - peaktemp int, - unitsales int -) PARTITION BY RANGE (logdate); +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); +... +CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS +ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE + ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) +DO INSTEAD + INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); </programlisting> + + A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead + is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might + be advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, + the trigger method will offer better performance. </para> - </listitem> - <listitem> <para> - Then create partitions as follows: + Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to + use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the + correct partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> + does fire triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger + approach. + </para> -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m03 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-03-01') TO ('2006-04-01'); -... -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m11 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-11-01') TO ('2007-12-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2007m12 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2007-12-01') TO ('2008-01-01'); -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m01 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-01-01') TO ('2008-02-01'); -</programlisting> + <para> + Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple + way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion + date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. </para> </listitem> <listitem> <para> - Create indexes on the key columns just like in case of inheritance - partitions. + Ensure that the <xref linkend="guc-constraint-exclusion"> + configuration parameter is not disabled in + <filename>postgresql.conf</>. + If it is, queries will not be optimized as desired. </para> </listitem> </orderedlist> - - <note> - <para> - To implement sub-partitioning, specify the - <literal>PARTITION BY</literal> clause in the commands used to create - individual partitions, for example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2006m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2006-02-01') TO ('2006-03-01') - PARTITION BY RANGE (peaktemp); -</programlisting> - - After creating partitions of <structname>measurement_y2006m02</>, any - data inserted into <structname>measurement</> that is mapped to - <structname>measurement_y2006m02</> will be further redirected to one - of its partitions based on the <structfield>peaktemp</> column. - Partition key specified may overlap with the parent's partition key, - although care must be taken when specifying the bounds of sub-partitions - such that the accepted set of data constitutes a subset of what a - partition's own bounds allows; the system does not try to check if - that's really the case. - </para> - </note> </para> <para> - As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a - substantial amount of DDL, although significantly less when using - partitioned tables. In the above example we would be creating a new - partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that - generates the required DDL automatically. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-managing-partitions"> - <title>Managing Partitions</title> - - <para> - Normally the set of partitions established when initially - defining the table are not intended to remain static. It is - common to want to remove old partitions of data and periodically - add new partitions for new data. One of the most important - advantages of partitioning is precisely that it allows this - otherwise painful task to be executed nearly instantaneously by - manipulating the partition structure, rather than physically moving large - amounts of data around. - </para> - - <para> - Both the inheritance-based and partitioned table methods allow this to - be done, although the latter requires taking an <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> - lock on the master table for various commands mentioned below. - </para> + As we can see, a complex partitioning scheme could require a + substantial amount of DDL. In the above example we would be creating + a new partition each month, so it might be wise to write a script that + generates the required DDL automatically. + </para> + </sect3> - <para> - The simplest option for removing old data is simply to drop the partition - that is no longer necessary, which works using both methods of - partitioning: + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-maintenance"> + <title>Partition Maintenance</title> + <para> + To remove old data quickly, simply to drop the partition that is no + longer necessary: <programlisting> DROP TABLE measurement_y2006m02; </programlisting> - This can very quickly delete millions of records because it doesn't have - to individually delete every record. - </para> + </para> <para> - Another option that is often preferable is to remove the partition from - the partitioned table but retain access to it as a table in its own - right: -<programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; -</programlisting> - - When using a partitioned table: + To remove the partition from the partitioned table but retain access to + it as a table in its own right: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement DETACH PARTITION measurement_y2006m02; +ALTER TABLE measurement_y2006m02 NO INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> - - This allows further operations to be performed on the data before - it is dropped. For example, this is often a useful time to back up - the data using <command>COPY</>, <application>pg_dump</>, or - similar tools. It might also be a useful time to aggregate data - into smaller formats, perform other data manipulations, or run - reports. </para> <para> - Similarly we can add a new partition to handle new data. We can create an - empty partition in the partitioned table just as the original partitions - were created above: + To add a new partition to handle new data, create an empty partition just + as the original partitions were created above: <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( @@ -3577,52 +3682,80 @@ CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ( ) INHERITS (measurement); </programlisting> - When using a partitioned table: - -<programlisting> -CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 PARTITION OF measurement - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01'); -</programlisting> - - As an alternative, it is sometimes more convenient to create the - new table outside the partition structure, and make it a proper - partition later. This allows the data to be loaded, checked, and - transformed prior to it appearing in the partitioned table: + Alternatively, one may created the new table outside the partition + structure, and make it a partition after data is loaded, checked, + and transformed. <programlisting> CREATE TABLE measurement_y2008m02 (LIKE measurement INCLUDING DEFAULTS INCLUDING CONSTRAINTS); + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 ADD CONSTRAINT y2008m02 CHECK ( logdate >= DATE '2008-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-03-01' ); + \copy measurement_y2008m02 from 'measurement_y2008m02' -- possibly some other data preparation work + ALTER TABLE measurement_y2008m02 INHERIT measurement; </programlisting> + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-inheritance-caveats"> + <title>Caveats</title> + + <para> + The following caveats apply to partitioned tables implemented using + inheritance: + <itemizedlist> + <listitem> + <para> + There is no automatic way to verify that all of the + <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually + exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates + partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than + to write each by hand. + </para> + </listitem> - The last of the above commands when using a partitioned table would be: + <listitem> + <para> + The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) + of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require + it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts + to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. + If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers + on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure + much more complicated. + </para> + </listitem> + <listitem> + <para> + If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or + <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that + you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: <programlisting> -ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 - FOR VALUES FROM ('2008-02-01') TO ('2008-03-01' ); +ANALYZE measurement; </programlisting> - </para> + will only process the master table. + </para> + </listitem> - <tip> + <listitem> <para> - Before running the <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> command, it is - recommended to create a <literal>CHECK</> constraint on the table to - be attached describing the desired partition constraint. Using the - same, system is able to skip the scan to validate the implicit - partition constraint. Without such a constraint, the table will be - scanned to validate the partition constraint, while holding an - <literal>ACCESS EXCLUSIVE</literal> lock on the parent table. - One may want to drop the constraint after <command>ATTACH PARTITION</> - is finished, because it is no longer necessary. + <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> + action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified + target relation, not its child relations. </para> - </tip> - </sect2> + </listitem> + </itemizedlist> + </para> + </sect3> + </sect2> - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-constraint-exclusion"> <title>Partitioning and Constraint Exclusion</title> <indexterm> @@ -3632,7 +3765,8 @@ ALTER TABLE measurement ATTACH PARTITION measurement_y2008m02 <para> <firstterm>Constraint exclusion</> is a query optimization technique that improves performance for partitioned tables defined in the - fashion described above. As an example: + fashion described above (both declarative partitioned tables and those + implemented using inheritance). As an example: <programlisting> SET constraint_exclusion = on; @@ -3715,153 +3849,6 @@ EXPLAIN SELECT count(*) FROM measurement WHERE logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01'; are unlikely to benefit. </para> - <note> - <para> - Currently, constraint exclusion is also used for partitioned tables. - However, we did not create any <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints - for individual partitions as seen above. In this case, the optimizer - uses internally generated constraint for every partition. - </para> - </note> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> - <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> - - <para> - A different approach to redirecting inserts into the appropriate - partition table is to set up rules, instead of a trigger, on the - master table (unless it is a partitioned table). For example: - -<programlisting> -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2006m02 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2006-02-01' AND logdate < DATE '2006-03-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2006m02 VALUES (NEW.*); -... -CREATE RULE measurement_insert_y2008m01 AS -ON INSERT TO measurement WHERE - ( logdate >= DATE '2008-01-01' AND logdate < DATE '2008-02-01' ) -DO INSTEAD - INSERT INTO measurement_y2008m01 VALUES (NEW.*); -</programlisting> - - A rule has significantly more overhead than a trigger, but the overhead - is paid once per query rather than once per row, so this method might be - advantageous for bulk-insert situations. In most cases, however, the - trigger method will offer better performance. - </para> - - <para> - Be aware that <command>COPY</> ignores rules. If you want to - use <command>COPY</> to insert data, you'll need to copy into the correct - partition table rather than into the master. <command>COPY</> does fire - triggers, so you can use it normally if you use the trigger approach. - </para> - - <para> - Another disadvantage of the rule approach is that there is no simple - way to force an error if the set of rules doesn't cover the insertion - date; the data will silently go into the master table instead. - </para> - - <para> - Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> - view, instead of table inheritance. For example, - -<programlisting> -CREATE VIEW measurement AS - SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 -... -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 -UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; -</programlisting> - - However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and - dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this - method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. - </para> - - </sect2> - - <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-caveats"> - <title>Caveats</title> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to using inheritance to implement partitioning: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - There is no automatic way to verify that all of the - <literal>CHECK</literal> constraints are mutually - exclusive. It is safer to create code that generates - partitions and creates and/or modifies associated objects than - to write each by hand. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - The schemes shown here assume that the partition key column(s) - of a row never change, or at least do not change enough to require - it to move to another partition. An <command>UPDATE</> that attempts - to do that will fail because of the <literal>CHECK</> constraints. - If you need to handle such cases, you can put suitable update triggers - on the partition tables, but it makes management of the structure - much more complicated. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - If you are using manual <command>VACUUM</command> or - <command>ANALYZE</command> commands, don't forget that - you need to run them on each partition individually. A command like: -<programlisting> -ANALYZE measurement; -</programlisting> - will only process the master table. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clauses are unlikely to work as expected, as the <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - action is only taken in case of unique violations on the specified - target relation, not its child relations. - </para> - </listitem> - </itemizedlist> - </para> - - <para> - The following caveats apply to partitioned tables created with the - explicit syntax: - <itemizedlist> - <listitem> - <para> - An <command>UPDATE</> that causes a row to move from one partition to - another fails, because the new value of the row fails to satisfy the - implicit partition constraint of the original partition. This might - change in future releases. - </para> - </listitem> - - <listitem> - <para> - <command>INSERT</command> statements with <literal>ON CONFLICT</> - clause are currently not allowed on partitioned tables. - </para> - </listitem> - - </itemizedlist> - </para> - <para> The following caveats apply to constraint exclusion, which is currently used by both inheritance and partitioned tables: @@ -3901,10 +3888,78 @@ ANALYZE measurement; don't try to use many thousands of partitions. </para> </listitem> - </itemizedlist> </para> </sect2> + + <sect2 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives"> + <title>Alternative Partitioning Methods</title> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-union-all"> + <title>Using UNION ALL view</title> + <para> + Partitioning can also be arranged using a <literal>UNION ALL</literal> + view, instead of table inheritance. For example, + +<programlisting> +CREATE VIEW measurement AS + SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m02 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2006m03 +... +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m11 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2007m12 +UNION ALL SELECT * FROM measurement_y2008m01; +</programlisting> + + However, the need to recreate the view adds an extra step to adding and + dropping individual partitions of the data set. In practice this + method has little to recommend it compared to using inheritance. + </para> + </sect3> + + <sect3 id="ddl-partitioning-alternatives-brin-index"> + <title>Accessing Tables Using BRIN Index</title> + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym>, which stands for Block Range Index, is + designed for handling very large tables in which certain columns + have some natural physical location within the table. For example, + in the <structname>measurement</structname> table, the entries for + earlier times (<structfield>logdate</structfield> column) will appear + earlier in the table most of the time. A table storing a ZIP code + column might have all codes for a city grouped together naturally. + </para> + + <para> + In case of <structname>measurement</structname> table, one may consider + adding a minmax <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index on the + <structfield>logdate</structfield> column. + +<programlisting> +CREATE INDEX ON measurement USING brin (logdate date_minmax_ops); +</programlisting> + + In this case, specifying <literal>date_minmax_ops</literal> is not + necessary; it is shown for clarity. + </para> + + <para> + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes leverage this locality of data and + store summary information for a range of consecutive pages and keep + it updated as the data is added or removed. Because a + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> index is very small, scanning the index adds + adds little overhead compared to a sequential scan, but may avoid + scanning large parts of the table that are known not to contain + matching tuples. That is often why table partitioning is used. Thus, + <acronym>BRIN</acronym> indexes provide a subset of benefits that + parttioning provides with much less upfront setup. + </para> + + <para> + See <xref linkend="brin"> for more details. + </para> + </sect3> + + </sect2> </sect1> <sect1 id="ddl-foreign-data"> -- 2.11.0 --------------19C79A137EF2D0DB3BE72F79 Content-Type: text/x-diff; name="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" Content-Transfer-Encoding: 7bit Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="0002-Add-a-note-about-DROP-NOT-NULL-and-partitions.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
* [PATCH v51 06/10] Error out any process that would block at REPACK @ 2026-04-01 15:35 Antonin Houska <[email protected]> 0 siblings, 0 replies; 50+ messages in thread From: Antonin Houska @ 2026-04-01 15:35 UTC (permalink / raw) Any process waiting on REPACK to release its lock would actually cause it to deadlock when it tries to upgrade its lock to AEL, losing all work done to that point. We avoid this by teaching the deadlock detector to raise an error when this condition is detected. --- src/backend/commands/repack.c | 60 ++++++++++---- src/backend/storage/lmgr/deadlock.c | 15 ++++ src/include/storage/proc.h | 6 +- src/test/modules/injection_points/Makefile | 1 + .../expected/repack_deadlock.out | 63 ++++++++++++++ src/test/modules/injection_points/meson.build | 1 + .../specs/repack_deadlock.spec | 83 +++++++++++++++++++ 7 files changed, 210 insertions(+), 19 deletions(-) create mode 100644 src/test/modules/injection_points/expected/repack_deadlock.out create mode 100644 src/test/modules/injection_points/specs/repack_deadlock.spec diff --git a/src/backend/commands/repack.c b/src/backend/commands/repack.c index 03829892d57..d6e446d582d 100644 --- a/src/backend/commands/repack.c +++ b/src/backend/commands/repack.c @@ -279,6 +279,21 @@ ExecRepack(ParseState *pstate, RepackStmt *stmt, bool isTopLevel) /* Determine the lock mode to use. */ lockmode = RepackLockLevel((params.options & CLUOPT_CONCURRENT) != 0); + /* + * If in concurrent mode, set the PROC_IN_CONCURRENT_REPACK flag. This + * makes the deadlock checker cause anyone that would conflict with us to + * error out. It's important to set this flag ahead of actually locking + * the relation; it won't of course affect anyone until we do have a lock + * that others can conflict with. + */ + if ((params.options & CLUOPT_CONCURRENT) != 0) + { + LWLockAcquire(ProcArrayLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); + MyProc->statusFlags |= PROC_IN_CONCURRENT_REPACK; + ProcGlobal->statusFlags[MyProc->pgxactoff] = MyProc->statusFlags; + LWLockRelease(ProcArrayLock); + } + /* * If a single relation is specified, process it and we're done ... unless * the relation is a partitioned table, in which case we fall through. @@ -479,11 +494,8 @@ RepackLockLevel(bool concurrent) * If indexOid is InvalidOid, the table will be rewritten in physical order * instead of index order. * - * Note that, in the concurrent case, the function releases the lock at some - * point, in order to get AccessExclusiveLock for the final steps (i.e. to - * swap the relation files). To make things simpler, the caller should expect - * OldHeap to be closed on return, regardless CLUOPT_CONCURRENT. (The - * AccessExclusiveLock is kept till the end of the transaction.) + * On return, OldHeap is closed but locked with AccessExclusiveLock - the lock + * will be released at end of the transaction. * * 'cmd' indicates which command is being executed, to be used for error * messages. @@ -515,10 +527,12 @@ cluster_rel(RepackCommand cmd, Relation OldHeap, Oid indexOid, /* * Make sure we're not in a transaction block. * - * The reason is that repack_setup_logical_decoding() could deadlock - * if there's an XID already assigned. It would be possible to run in - * a transaction block if we had no XID, but this restriction is - * simpler for users to understand and we don't lose anything. + * The reason is that repack_setup_logical_decoding() could wait + * indefinitely for our XID to complete. (The deadlock detector would + * not recognize it because we'd be waiting for ourselves, i.e. no + * real lock conflict.) It would be possible to run in a transaction + * block if we had no XID, but this restriction is simpler for users + * to understand and we don't lose anything. */ PreventInTransactionBlock(isTopLevel, "REPACK (CONCURRENTLY)"); @@ -1001,10 +1015,8 @@ rebuild_relation(Relation OldHeap, Relation index, bool verbose, * Note that the worker has to wait for all transactions with XID * already assigned to finish. If some of those transactions is * waiting for a lock conflicting with ShareUpdateExclusiveLock on our - * table (e.g. it runs CREATE INDEX), we can end up in a deadlock. - * Not sure this risk is worth unlocking/locking the table (and its - * clustering index) and checking again if it's still eligible for - * REPACK CONCURRENTLY. + * table (e.g. it runs CREATE INDEX), it should encounter ERROR in the + * deadlock checking code. */ start_repack_decoding_worker(tableOid); @@ -3093,7 +3105,19 @@ rebuild_relation_finish_concurrent(Relation NewHeap, Relation OldHeap, LockRelationOid(OldHeap->rd_rel->reltoastrelid, AccessExclusiveLock); /* - * Tuples and pages of the old heap will be gone, but the heap will stay. + * Now that we have all access-exclusive locks on all relations, we no + * longer want other processes to error out when trying to acquire a + * conflicting lock. Therefore, unset our flag. + */ + LWLockAcquire(ProcArrayLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); + MyProc->statusFlags &= ~PROC_IN_CONCURRENT_REPACK; + ProcGlobal->statusFlags[MyProc->pgxactoff] = MyProc->statusFlags; + LWLockRelease(ProcArrayLock); + + /* + * Tuples and pages of the old heap will be gone, but the heap itself will + * stay. In order for predicate locks to continue to work, convert them + * to relation-level locks. We do this both for table and indexes. */ TransferPredicateLocksToHeapRelation(OldHeap); foreach_ptr(RelationData, index, indexrels) @@ -3366,9 +3390,11 @@ start_repack_decoding_worker(Oid relid) /* * The decoding setup must be done before the caller can have XID assigned - * for any reason, otherwise the worker might end up in a deadlock, - * waiting for the caller's transaction to end. Therefore wait here until - * the worker indicates that it has the logical decoding initialized. + * for any reason, otherwise the worker might end up waiting for the + * caller's transaction to end. (Deadlock detector does not consider this + * a conflict because the worker is in the same locking group as the + * backend that launched it.) Therefore wait here until the worker + * indicates that it has the logical decoding initialized. */ ConditionVariablePrepareToSleep(&shared->cv); for (;;) diff --git a/src/backend/storage/lmgr/deadlock.c b/src/backend/storage/lmgr/deadlock.c index b8962d875b6..c20ac682b0d 100644 --- a/src/backend/storage/lmgr/deadlock.c +++ b/src/backend/storage/lmgr/deadlock.c @@ -620,6 +620,21 @@ FindLockCycleRecurseMember(PGPROC *checkProc, proc->statusFlags & PROC_IS_AUTOVACUUM) blocking_autovacuum_proc = proc; + /* + * Similarly, if we note that we're blocked by some + * process running REPACK (CONCURRENTLY), just fail. That + * process is going to upgrade its lock at some point, and + * it would be inappropriate for any other process to + * cause that to fail. + */ + if (checkProc == MyProc && + proc->statusFlags & PROC_IN_CONCURRENT_REPACK) + ereport(ERROR, + errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_IN_USE), + errmsg("could not wait for concurrent REPACK"), + errdetail("Process %d waits for REPACK running on process %d", + MyProc->pid, proc->pid)); + /* We're done looking at this proclock */ break; } diff --git a/src/include/storage/proc.h b/src/include/storage/proc.h index 1dad125706e..8ad9718f3d6 100644 --- a/src/include/storage/proc.h +++ b/src/include/storage/proc.h @@ -69,10 +69,12 @@ struct XidCache #define PROC_AFFECTS_ALL_HORIZONS 0x20 /* this proc's xmin must be * included in vacuum horizons * in all databases */ +#define PROC_IN_CONCURRENT_REPACK 0x40 /* REPACK (CONCURRENTLY) */ -/* flags reset at EOXact */ +/* flags reset at EOXact. A bit of a misnomer ... */ #define PROC_VACUUM_STATE_MASK \ - (PROC_IN_VACUUM | PROC_IN_SAFE_IC | PROC_VACUUM_FOR_WRAPAROUND) + (PROC_IN_VACUUM | PROC_IN_SAFE_IC | PROC_VACUUM_FOR_WRAPAROUND | \ + PROC_IN_CONCURRENT_REPACK) /* * Xmin-related flags. Make sure any flags that affect how the process' Xmin diff --git a/src/test/modules/injection_points/Makefile b/src/test/modules/injection_points/Makefile index 2cd7d87c533..f7663859fe2 100644 --- a/src/test/modules/injection_points/Makefile +++ b/src/test/modules/injection_points/Makefile @@ -15,6 +15,7 @@ REGRESS_OPTS = --dlpath=$(top_builddir)/src/test/regress ISOLATION = basic \ inplace \ repack \ + repack_deadlock \ repack_toast \ syscache-update-pruned \ heap_lock_update diff --git a/src/test/modules/injection_points/expected/repack_deadlock.out b/src/test/modules/injection_points/expected/repack_deadlock.out new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..a86e4767536 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/test/modules/injection_points/expected/repack_deadlock.out @@ -0,0 +1,63 @@ +Parsed test spec with 2 sessions + +starting permutation: wait_before_lock add_column wakeup_before_lock check1 +injection_points_attach +----------------------- + +(1 row) + +step wait_before_lock: + REPACK (CONCURRENTLY) repack_deadlock USING INDEX repack_deadlock_pkey; + <waiting ...> +step add_column: + alter table repack_deadlock add column noise text; + <waiting ...> +step add_column: <... completed> +ERROR: could not wait for concurrent REPACK +step wakeup_before_lock: + SELECT injection_points_wakeup('repack-concurrently-before-lock'); + +injection_points_wakeup +----------------------- + +(1 row) + +step wait_before_lock: <... completed> +step check1: + INSERT INTO relfilenodes(node) + SELECT relfilenode FROM pg_class WHERE relname='repack_deadlock'; + + SELECT count(DISTINCT node) FROM relfilenodes; + + SELECT i, j FROM repack_deadlock ORDER BY i, j; + + INSERT INTO data_s1(i, j) + SELECT i, j FROM repack_deadlock; + + SELECT count(*) + FROM data_s1 d1 FULL JOIN data_s2 d2 USING (i, j) + WHERE d1.i ISNULL OR d2.i ISNULL; + +count +----- + 1 +(1 row) + +i|j +-+- +1|1 +2|2 +3|3 +4|4 +(4 rows) + +count +----- + 4 +(1 row) + +injection_points_detach +----------------------- + +(1 row) + diff --git a/src/test/modules/injection_points/meson.build b/src/test/modules/injection_points/meson.build index a414abb924b..1cd88d6db65 100644 --- a/src/test/modules/injection_points/meson.build +++ b/src/test/modules/injection_points/meson.build @@ -46,6 +46,7 @@ tests += { 'basic', 'inplace', 'repack', + 'repack_deadlock', 'repack_toast', 'syscache-update-pruned', 'heap_lock_update', diff --git a/src/test/modules/injection_points/specs/repack_deadlock.spec b/src/test/modules/injection_points/specs/repack_deadlock.spec new file mode 100644 index 00000000000..9d23a6588c2 --- /dev/null +++ b/src/test/modules/injection_points/specs/repack_deadlock.spec @@ -0,0 +1,83 @@ +# Test REPACK with a concurrent transaction that would cause a deadlock +setup +{ + CREATE EXTENSION injection_points; + + CREATE TABLE repack_deadlock(i int PRIMARY KEY, j int); + INSERT INTO repack_deadlock(i, j) VALUES (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), (4, 4); + + CREATE TABLE relfilenodes(node oid); + + CREATE TABLE data_s1(i int, j int); + CREATE TABLE data_s2(i int, j int); +} + +teardown +{ + DROP TABLE repack_deadlock; + DROP EXTENSION injection_points; + + DROP TABLE relfilenodes; + DROP TABLE data_s1; + DROP TABLE data_s2; +} + +session s1 +setup +{ + SELECT injection_points_set_local(); + SELECT injection_points_attach('repack-concurrently-before-lock', 'wait'); +} +# Perform the initial load and wait for s2 to do some data changes. +step wait_before_lock +{ + REPACK (CONCURRENTLY) repack_deadlock USING INDEX repack_deadlock_pkey; +} +# Check the table from the perspective of s1. +# +# Besides the contents, we also check that relfilenode has changed. + +# Have each session write the contents into a table and use FULL JOIN to check +# if the outputs are identical. +step check1 +{ + INSERT INTO relfilenodes(node) + SELECT relfilenode FROM pg_class WHERE relname='repack_deadlock'; + + SELECT count(DISTINCT node) FROM relfilenodes; + + SELECT i, j FROM repack_deadlock ORDER BY i, j; + + INSERT INTO data_s1(i, j) + SELECT i, j FROM repack_deadlock; + + SELECT count(*) + FROM data_s1 d1 FULL JOIN data_s2 d2 USING (i, j) + WHERE d1.i ISNULL OR d2.i ISNULL; +} +teardown +{ + SELECT injection_points_detach('repack-concurrently-before-lock'); +} + +session s2 +# Change the existing data. UPDATE changes both key and non-key columns. Also +# update one row twice to test whether tuple version generated by this session +# can be found. +step add_column +{ + alter table repack_deadlock add column noise text; +} + +step wakeup_before_lock +{ + SELECT injection_points_wakeup('repack-concurrently-before-lock'); +} + +# Test if data changes introduced while one session is performing REPACK +# CONCURRENTLY find their way into the table. +permutation + wait_before_lock + add_column + wakeup_before_lock + check1 -- 2.47.3 --r2slln3zpmilwu22 Content-Type: text/x-diff; charset=utf-8 Content-Disposition: attachment; filename="v51-0007-Check-for-transaction-block-early-in-ExecRepack.patch" ^ permalink raw reply [nested|flat] 50+ messages in thread
end of thread, other threads:[~2026-04-01 15:35 UTC | newest] Thread overview: 50+ messages (download: mbox mbox.gz follow: Atom feed) -- links below jump to the message on this page -- 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2017-03-03 07:39 [PATCH 1/3] Rewrite sections in ddl.sgml related to partitioning amit <[email protected]> 2026-04-01 15:35 [PATCH v51 06/10] Error out any process that would block at REPACK Antonin Houska <[email protected]>
This inbox is served by agora; see mirroring instructions for how to clone and mirror all data and code used for this inbox